1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2025 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <linux/android_kabi.h>
23 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
24 #include <net/codel.h>
25 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
26 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
32  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
33  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
34  * drivers.
35  */
36 
37 /**
38  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
39  *
40  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
41  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
42  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
43  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
44  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
45  * tasklet function.
46  *
47  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
48  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
49  */
50 
51 /**
52  * DOC: Warning
53  *
54  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
55  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
56  */
57 
58 /**
59  * DOC: Frame format
60  *
61  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
62  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
63  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
64  * hardware.
65  *
66  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
67  *
68  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
69  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
70  *
71  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
72  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
73  */
74 
75 /**
76  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
77  *
78  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
79  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
80  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
81  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
82  *
83  * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
84  * suspend.
85  *
86  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
87  *
88  */
89 
90 /**
91  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
92  *
93  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
94  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
95  * different stations/interfaces.
96  *
97  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
98  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
99  * handler.
100  *
101  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
102  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
103  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
104  *
105  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
106  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
107  *
108  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
109  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
110  * driver op.
111  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
112  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
113  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
114  *
115  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
116  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
117  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
118  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
119  * ieee80211_return_txq().
120  *
121  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
122  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
123  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
124  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
125  * .release_buffered_frames().
126  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
127  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
128  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
129  */
130 
131 /**
132  * DOC: HW timestamping
133  *
134  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
135  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
136  *
137  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
138  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
139  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
140  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
141  *
142  * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
143  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
144  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
145  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
146  */
147 struct device;
148 
149 /**
150  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
151  *
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
153  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
154  */
155 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
157 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
158 };
159 
160 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
161 
162 /**
163  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
167  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
168  */
169 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
173 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
174 };
175 
176 /**
177  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
178  *
179  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
180  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
181  *
182  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
183  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
184  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
185  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
186  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
187  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
188  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
189  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
190  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
191  */
192 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
193 	u16 txop;
194 	u16 cw_min;
195 	u16 cw_max;
196 	u8 aifs;
197 	bool acm;
198 	bool uapsd;
199 	bool mu_edca;
200 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
201 };
202 
203 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
204 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
207 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
208 };
209 
210 /**
211  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
215  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
216  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
217  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
218  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
219  *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
220  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
221  *	was changed.
222  */
223 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
224 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
225 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
226 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
227 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
228 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
229 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
230 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
231 };
232 
233 /**
234  * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
235  * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
236  * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
237  *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
238  */
239 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
240 	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
241 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
242 };
243 
244 /**
245  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
246  *
247  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
248  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
249  *
250  * @def: the channel definition
251  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
252  * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
253  *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
254  * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
255  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
256  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
257  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
258  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
259  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
260  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
261  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
262  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
263  */
264 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
265 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
266 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
267 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
268 
269 	int radio_idx;
270 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
271 
272 	bool radar_enabled;
273 
274 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
275 };
276 
277 /**
278  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
279  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
280  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
281  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
282  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
283  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
284  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
285  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
286  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
287  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
288  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
289  *      for changes/removal.)
290  */
291 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
292 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
293 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
294 };
295 
296 /**
297  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
298  *
299  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
300  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
301  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
302  * done.
303  *
304  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
305  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
306  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
307  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
308  */
309 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
310 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
311 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
312 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
313 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
314 };
315 
316 /**
317  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
318  *
319  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
320  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
321  *
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
323  *	also implies a change in the AID.
324  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
326  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
328  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
329  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
331  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
333  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
335  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
336  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
340  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
342  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
344  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
345  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
346  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
347  *	changed
348  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
349  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
350  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
351  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
352  *	context had been assigned.
353  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
354  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
355  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
356  *	keep alive) changed.
357  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
358  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
359  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
360  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
361  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
362  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
363  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
364  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
365  *	status changed.
366  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
367  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
368  * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
369  */
370 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
371 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
379 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
380 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
381 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
382 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
383 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
384 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
385 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
386 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
387 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
388 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
389 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
390 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
391 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
392 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
393 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
394 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
395 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
396 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
397 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
398 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
399 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
400 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
401 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
402 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
403 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
404 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
405 	BSS_CHANGED_TPE			= BIT_ULL(35),
406 
407 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
408 };
409 
410 /*
411  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
412  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
413  * filtering will be disabled.
414  */
415 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
416 
417 /**
418  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
419  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
420  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
421  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
422  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
423  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
424  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
425  */
426 enum ieee80211_event_type {
427 	RSSI_EVENT,
428 	MLME_EVENT,
429 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
430 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
431 };
432 
433 /**
434  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
435  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
436  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
437  */
438 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
439 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
440 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
441 };
442 
443 /**
444  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
445  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
446  */
447 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
448 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
449 };
450 
451 /**
452  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
453  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
454  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
455  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
456  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
457  */
458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
459 	AUTH_EVENT,
460 	ASSOC_EVENT,
461 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
462 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
463 };
464 
465 /**
466  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
467  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
468  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
469  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
470  */
471 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
472 	MLME_SUCCESS,
473 	MLME_DENIED,
474 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
475 };
476 
477 /**
478  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
479  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
480  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
481  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
482  */
483 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
484 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
485 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
486 	u16 reason;
487 };
488 
489 /**
490  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
491  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
492  * @tid: the tid
493  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
494  */
495 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
496 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
497 	u16 tid;
498 	u16 ssn;
499 };
500 
501 /**
502  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
503  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
504  * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
505  * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
506  * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
507  * @u:union holding the fields above
508  */
509 struct ieee80211_event {
510 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
511 	union {
512 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
513 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
514 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
515 	} u;
516 };
517 
518 /**
519  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
520  *
521  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
522  *
523  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
524  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
525  */
526 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
527 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
528 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
529 };
530 
531 /**
532  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
533  *
534  * @lci: LCI subelement content
535  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
536  * @lci_len: LCI data length
537  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
538  */
539 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
540 	const u8 *lci;
541 	const u8 *civicloc;
542 	size_t lci_len;
543 	size_t civicloc_len;
544 };
545 
546 /**
547  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
548  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
549  *
550  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
552  */
553 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
554 	u32 min_interval;
555 	u32 max_interval;
556 };
557 
558 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ	5
559 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
560 	bool valid;
561 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
562 	u8 count;
563 };
564 
565 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ	16
566 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
567 	bool valid;
568 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
569 	u8 count, n;
570 };
571 
572 /**
573  * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
574  * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
575  *	(indexed by TX power category)
576  * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
577  *	160, 320 MHz each
578  *	(indexed by TX power category)
579  * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
580  *	subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
581  *	(indexed by TX power category)
582  * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
583  *	each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
584  *	(indexed by TX power category)
585  */
586 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
587 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
588 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
589 };
590 
591 /**
592  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
593  *
594  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
595  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
596  *
597  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
598  * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
599  *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
600  *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
601  *	responses.
602  * @addr: (link) address used locally
603  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
604  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
605  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
606  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
607  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
608  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
609  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
610  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
611  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
612  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
613  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
614  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
615  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
616  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
617  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
618  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
619  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
620  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
621  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
622  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
623  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
624  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
625  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
626  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
627  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
628  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
629  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
630  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
631  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
632  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
633  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
634  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
635  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
636  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
637  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
638  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
639  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
640  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
641  *	the current band.
642  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
643  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
644  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
645  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
646  * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
647  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
648  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
649  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
650  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
651  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
652  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
653  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
654  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
655  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
656  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
657  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
658  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
659  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
660  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
661  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
662  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
663  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
664  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
665  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
666  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
667  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
668  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
669  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
670  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
671  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
672  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
673  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
674  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
675  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
676  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
677  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
678  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
679  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
680  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
681  *	station.
682  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
683  *	responder functionality.
684  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
685  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
686  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
687  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
688  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
689  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
690  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
691  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
692  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
693  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
694  *	connected to (STA)
695  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
696  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
697  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
698  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
699  *	interval.
700  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
701  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
702  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
703  * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
704  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
705  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
706  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
707  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
708  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
709  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
710  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
711  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
712  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
713  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
714  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
715  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
716  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
717  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
718  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
719  *	beamformer
720  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
721  *	beamformee
722  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
723  *	beamformer
724  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
725  *	beamformee
726  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
727  *	beamformer
728  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
729  *	beamformee
730  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
731  *	beamformer
732  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
733  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
734  *	bandwidth
735  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
736  *	beamformer
737  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
738  *	beamformee
739  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
740  *	beamformer
741  * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
742  *	reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
743  *	bandwidth
744  */
745 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
746 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
747 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
748 
749 	const u8 *bssid;
750 	unsigned int link_id;
751 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
752 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
753 	bool uora_exists;
754 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
755 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
756 	bool he_support;
757 	bool twt_requester;
758 	bool twt_responder;
759 	bool twt_protected;
760 	bool twt_broadcast;
761 	/* erp related data */
762 	bool use_cts_prot;
763 	bool use_short_preamble;
764 	bool use_short_slot;
765 	bool enable_beacon;
766 	u8 dtim_period;
767 	u16 beacon_int;
768 	u16 assoc_capability;
769 	u64 sync_tsf;
770 	u32 sync_device_ts;
771 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
772 	u32 basic_rates;
773 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
774 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
775 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
776 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
777 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
778 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
779 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
780 	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
781 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
782 	bool qos;
783 	bool hidden_ssid;
784 	int txpower;
785 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
786 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
787 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
788 	u16 max_idle_period;
789 	bool protected_keep_alive;
790 	bool ftm_responder;
791 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
792 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
793 	bool nontransmitted;
794 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
795 	u8 bssid_index;
796 	u8 bssid_indicator;
797 	bool ema_ap;
798 	u8 profile_periodicity;
799 	struct {
800 		u32 params;
801 		u16 nss_set;
802 	} he_oper;
803 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
804 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
805 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
806 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
807 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
808 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
809 
810 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
811 
812 	u8 pwr_reduction;
813 	bool eht_support;
814 
815 	bool csa_active;
816 
817 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
818 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
819 
820 	bool color_change_active;
821 	u8 color_change_color;
822 
823 	bool ht_ldpc;
824 	bool vht_ldpc;
825 	bool he_ldpc;
826 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
827 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
828 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
829 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
830 	bool he_su_beamformer;
831 	bool he_su_beamformee;
832 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
833 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
834 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
835 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
836 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
837 	bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
838 
839 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
840 };
841 
842 /**
843  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
844  *
845  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
846  *
847  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
848  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
849  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
850  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
851  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
852  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
853  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
854  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
855  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
856  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
857  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
858  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
859  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
860  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
861  *	station
862  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
863  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
864  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
865  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
866  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
867  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
868  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
869  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
870  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
871  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
872  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
873  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
874  *	hardware queue.
875  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
876  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
877  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
878  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
879  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
880  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
881  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
882  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
883  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
884  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
885  *	off-channel operation.
886  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
887  *	(header conversion)
888  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
889  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
890  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
891  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
892  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
893  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
894  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
895  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
896  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
897  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
898  *	queue gets full.
899  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
900  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
901  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
902  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
903  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
904  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
905  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
906  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
907  *	status to user space)
908  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
909  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
910  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
911  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
912  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
913  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
914  *	handled properly by the device.
915  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
916  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
917  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
918  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
919  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
920  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
921  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
922  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
923  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
924  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
925  *	PS-Poll responses.
926  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
927  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
928  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
929  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
930  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
931  *	monitor injection).
932  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
933  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
934  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
935  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
936  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
937  *
938  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
939  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
940  */
941 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
942 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
943 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
944 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
945 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
946 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
947 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
948 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
949 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
950 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
951 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
952 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
953 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
954 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
955 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
956 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
957 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
958 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
959 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
960 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
961 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
962 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
963 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
964 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
965 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
966 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
967 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
968 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
969 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
970 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
971 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
972 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
973 };
974 
975 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
976 
977 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
978 
979 /**
980  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
981  *
982  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
983  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
984  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
985  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
986  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
987  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
988  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
989  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
990  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
991  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
992  *	it can be sent out.
993  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
994  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
995  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
996  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
997  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
998  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
999  *	for sequence number assignment
1000  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1001  *	which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1002  *	operation on the interface.
1003  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1004  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1005  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1006  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1007  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1008  *	it's intended for an MLD.
1009  *
1010  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1011  */
1012 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1013 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
1014 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
1015 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
1016 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
1017 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
1018 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
1019 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
1020 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
1021 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
1022 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
1023 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK	= BIT(10),
1024 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
1025 };
1026 
1027 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
1028 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
1029 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1030 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1031 
1032 /**
1033  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1034  *
1035  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1036  *
1037  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1038  */
1039 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1040 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1041 };
1042 
1043 /*
1044  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1045  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1046  */
1047 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1048 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1049 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1050 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1051 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1052 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1053 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1054 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1055 
1056 /**
1057  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1058  *	Rate Control algorithm.
1059  *
1060  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1061  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1062  *
1063  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1064  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1065  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1066  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1067  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1068  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1069  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1070  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1071  *	Greenfield mode.
1072  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1073  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1074  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1075  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1076  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1077  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1078  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1079  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1080  */
1081 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1082 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1083 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1084 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1085 
1086 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1087 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1088 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1089 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1090 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1091 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1092 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1093 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1094 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1095 };
1096 
1097 
1098 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1099 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1100 
1101 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1102 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1103 
1104 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1105 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1106 
1107 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1108 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1109 
1110 /**
1111  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1112  *
1113  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1114  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1115  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1116  *
1117  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1118  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1119  *
1120  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1121  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1122  *
1123  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1124  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1125  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1126  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1127  * information::
1128  *
1129  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1130  *
1131  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1132  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1133  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1134  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1135  * information should then contain::
1136  *
1137  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1138  *
1139  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1140  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1141  */
1142 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1143 	s8 idx;
1144 	u16 count:5,
1145 	    flags:11;
1146 } __packed;
1147 
1148 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1149 
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1150 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1151 {
1152 	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1153 }
1154 
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1155 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1156 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1157 {
1158 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1159 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1160 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1161 }
1162 
1163 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1164 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1165 {
1166 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1167 }
1168 
1169 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1170 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1171 {
1172 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1173 }
1174 
1175 /**
1176  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1177  *
1178  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1179  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1180  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1181  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1182  *
1183  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1184  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1185  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1186  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1187  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1188  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1189  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1190  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1191  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1192  * @control: union part for control data
1193  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1194  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1195  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1196  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1197  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1198  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1199  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1200  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1201  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1202  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1203  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1204  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1205  * @pad: padding
1206  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1207  * @status: union part for status data
1208  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1209  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1210  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1211  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1212  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1213  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1214  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1215  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1216  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1217  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1218  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1219  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1220  */
1221 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1222 	/* common information */
1223 	u32 flags;
1224 	u32 band:3,
1225 	    status_data_idr:1,
1226 	    status_data:13,
1227 	    hw_queue:4,
1228 	    tx_time_est:10;
1229 	/* 1 free bit */
1230 
1231 	union {
1232 		struct {
1233 			union {
1234 				/* rate control */
1235 				struct {
1236 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1237 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1238 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1239 					u8 use_rts:1;
1240 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1241 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1242 					u8 skip_table:1;
1243 
1244 					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1245 					u8 antennas:2;
1246 
1247 					/* 14 bits free */
1248 				};
1249 				/* only needed before rate control */
1250 				unsigned long jiffies;
1251 			};
1252 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1253 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1254 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1255 			u32 flags;
1256 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1257 		} control;
1258 		struct {
1259 			u64 cookie;
1260 		} ack;
1261 		struct {
1262 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1263 			s32 ack_signal;
1264 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1265 			u8 ampdu_len;
1266 			u8 antenna;
1267 			u8 pad;
1268 			u16 tx_time;
1269 			u8 flags;
1270 			u8 pad2;
1271 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1272 		} status;
1273 		struct {
1274 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1275 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1276 			u8 pad[4];
1277 
1278 			void *rate_driver_data[
1279 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1280 		};
1281 
1282 		ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1283 
1284 		void *driver_data[
1285 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1286 	};
1287 };
1288 
1289 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1290 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1291 {
1292 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1293 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1294 	 */
1295 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1296 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1297 }
1298 
1299 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1300 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1301 {
1302 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1303 }
1304 
1305 /***
1306  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1307  *
1308  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1309  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1310  *
1311  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1312  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1313  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1314  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1315  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1316  */
1317 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1318 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1319 	u8 try_count;
1320 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1321 };
1322 
1323 /**
1324  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1325  *
1326  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1327  * @info: Basic tx status information
1328  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1329  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1330  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1331  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1332  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1333  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1334  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1335  */
1336 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1337 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1338 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1339 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1340 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1341 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1342 	u8 n_rates;
1343 
1344 	struct list_head *free_list;
1345 };
1346 
1347 /**
1348  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1349  *
1350  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1351  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1352  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1353  *
1354  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1355  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1356  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1357  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1358  */
1359 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1360 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1361 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1362 	const u8 *common_ies;
1363 	size_t common_ie_len;
1364 };
1365 
1366 
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1367 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1368 {
1369 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1370 }
1371 
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1372 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1373 {
1374 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1375 }
1376 
1377 /**
1378  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1379  *
1380  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1381  *
1382  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1383  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1384  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1385  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1386  *
1387  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1388  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1389  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1390  */
1391 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1392 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1393 {
1394 	int i;
1395 
1396 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1397 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1398 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1399 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1400 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1401 	/* clear the rate counts */
1402 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1403 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1404 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1405 }
1406 
1407 
1408 /**
1409  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1410  *
1411  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1412  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1413  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1414  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1415  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1416  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1417  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1418  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1419  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1420  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1421  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1422  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1423  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1424  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1425  *	de-duplication by itself.
1426  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1427  *	the frame.
1428  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1429  *	the frame.
1430  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1431  *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1432  *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1433  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1434  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1435  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1436  *	merging.
1437  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1438  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1439  *	(including FCS) was received.
1440  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1441  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1442  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1443  *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1444  *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1445  *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1446  *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1447  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1448  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1449  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1450  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1451  *	each A-MPDU
1452  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1453  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1454  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1455  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1456  *	on this subframe
1457  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1458  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1459  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1460  *	done by the hardware
1461  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1462  *	processing it in any regular way.
1463  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1464  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1465  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1466  *	monitor interfaces.
1467  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1468  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1469  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1470  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1471  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1472  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1473  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1474  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1475  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1476  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1477  *	interleaved with other frames.
1478  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1479  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1480  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1481  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1482  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1483  *	in the skb.
1484  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1485  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1486  *	the first subframe.
1487  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1488  *	be done in the hardware.
1489  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1490  *	frame
1491  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1492  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1493  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1494  *
1495  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1496  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1497  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1498  *	 - DATA5_GI
1499  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1500  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1501  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1502  *
1503  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1504  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1505  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1506  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1507  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1508  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1509  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1510  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1511  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1512  *	hardware or driver)
1513  */
1514 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1515 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1516 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1517 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1518 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1519 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1520 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1521 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1522 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1523 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1524 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1525 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1526 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1527 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1528 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1529 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1530 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1531 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1532 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1533 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1534 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1535 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1536 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1537 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1538 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1539 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1540 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1541 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1542 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1543 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1544 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1545 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1546 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1547 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1548 };
1549 
1550 /**
1551  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1552  *
1553  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1554  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1555  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1556  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1557  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1558  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1559  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1560  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1561  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1562  */
1563 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1564 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1565 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1566 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1567 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1568 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1569 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1570 };
1571 
1572 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1573 
1574 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1575 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1576 	RX_ENC_HT,
1577 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1578 	RX_ENC_HE,
1579 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1580 };
1581 
1582 /**
1583  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1584  *
1585  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1586  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1587  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1588  *
1589  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1590  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1591  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1592  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1593  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1594  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1595  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1596  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1597  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1598  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1599  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1600  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1601  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1602  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1603  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1604  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1605  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1606  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1607  *	values were filled.
1608  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1609  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1610  * @antenna: antenna used
1611  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1612  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1613  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1614  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1615  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1616  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1617  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1618  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1619  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1620  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1621  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1622  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1623  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1624  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1625  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1626  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1627  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1628  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1629  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1630  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1631  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1632  *	@link_valid.
1633  */
1634 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1635 	u64 mactime;
1636 	union {
1637 		u64 boottime_ns;
1638 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1639 	};
1640 	u32 device_timestamp;
1641 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1642 	u32 flag;
1643 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1644 	u8 enc_flags;
1645 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1646 	union {
1647 		struct {
1648 			u8 he_ru:3;
1649 			u8 he_gi:2;
1650 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1651 		};
1652 		struct {
1653 			u8 ru:4;
1654 			u8 gi:2;
1655 		} eht;
1656 	};
1657 	u8 rate_idx;
1658 	u8 nss;
1659 	u8 rx_flags;
1660 	u8 band;
1661 	u8 antenna;
1662 	s8 signal;
1663 	u8 chains;
1664 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1665 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1666 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1667 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1668 };
1669 
1670 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1671 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1672 {
1673 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1674 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1675 }
1676 
1677 /**
1678  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1679  *
1680  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1681  *
1682  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1683  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1684  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1685  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1686  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1687  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1688  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1689  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1690  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1691  *	for more.
1692  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1693  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1694  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1695  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1696  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1697  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1698  *	operating channel.
1699  */
1700 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1701 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1702 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1703 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1704 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1705 };
1706 
1707 
1708 /**
1709  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1710  *
1711  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1712  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1713  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1714  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1715  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1716  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1717  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1718  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1719  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1720  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1721  */
1722 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1723 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1724 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1725 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1726 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1727 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1728 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1729 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1730 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1731 };
1732 
1733 /**
1734  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1735  *
1736  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1737  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1738  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1739  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1740  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1741  */
1742 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1743 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1744 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1745 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1746 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1747 
1748 	/* keep last */
1749 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1750 };
1751 
1752 /**
1753  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1754  *
1755  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1756  *
1757  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1758  *
1759  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1760  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1761  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1762  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1763  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1764  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1765  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1766  *
1767  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1768  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1769  *
1770  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1771  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1772  *
1773  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1774  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1775  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1776  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1777  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1778  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1779  *
1780  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1781  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1782  *	configured for an HT channel.
1783  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1784  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1785  */
1786 struct ieee80211_conf {
1787 	u32 flags;
1788 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1789 
1790 	u16 listen_interval;
1791 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1792 
1793 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1794 
1795 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1796 	bool radar_enabled;
1797 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1798 
1799 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1800 };
1801 
1802 /**
1803  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1804  *
1805  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1806  * operation.
1807  *
1808  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1809  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1810  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1811  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1812  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1813  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1814  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1815  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1816  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1817  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1818  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1819  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1820  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1821  * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1822  */
1823 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1824 	u64 timestamp;
1825 	u32 device_timestamp;
1826 	bool block_tx;
1827 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1828 	u8 count;
1829 	u8 link_id;
1830 	u32 delay;
1831 };
1832 
1833 /**
1834  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1835  *
1836  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1837  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1838  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1839  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1840  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1841  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1842  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1843  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1844  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1845  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1846  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1847  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1848  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1849  * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1850  *      enabled for the interface.
1851  * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1852  *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1853  *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1854  *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1855  */
1856 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1857 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1858 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1859 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1860 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1861 	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1862 	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1863 };
1864 
1865 
1866 /**
1867  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1868  *
1869  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1870  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1871  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1872  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1873  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1874  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1875  *	mac80211.
1876  */
1877 
1878 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1879 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1880 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1881 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1882 };
1883 
1884 /**
1885  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1886  * @assoc: association status
1887  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1888  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1889  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1890  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1891  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1892  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1893  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1894  *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1895  * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1896  *	Figure 9-1001k
1897  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1898  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1899  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1900  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1901  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1902  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1903  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1904  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1905  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1906  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1907  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1908  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1909  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1910  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1911  *	(station mode only)
1912  */
1913 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1914 	/* association related data */
1915 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1916 	bool ibss_creator;
1917 	bool ps;
1918 	u16 aid;
1919 	u16 eml_cap;
1920 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1921 	u16 mld_capa_op;
1922 
1923 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1924 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1925 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1926 	size_t ssid_len;
1927 	bool s1g;
1928 	bool idle;
1929 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1930 };
1931 
1932 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1933 
1934 /**
1935  * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1936  *
1937  * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1938  *	this TID is not included.
1939  * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1940  *	TID is not included.
1941  * @valid: info is valid or not.
1942  */
1943 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1944 	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1945 	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1946 	bool valid;
1947 };
1948 
1949 /**
1950  * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1951  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1952  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1953  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1954  */
1955 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1956 	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1957 	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1958 	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1959 };
1960 
1961 /**
1962  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1963  *
1964  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1965  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1966  *
1967  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1968  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1969  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1970  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1971  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1972  *	indexed by link ID
1973  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1974  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1975  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1976  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1977  * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1978  *	due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1979  *	0 for non-MLO.
1980  * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1981  *	suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
1982  *	future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
1983  *	0 for non-MLO.
1984  * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1985  *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1986  * @addr: address of this interface
1987  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1988  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1989  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1990  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1991  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1992  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1993  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1994  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1995  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1996  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1997  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1998  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1999  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2000  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2001  *	restrictions.
2002  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2003  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2004  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2005  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2006  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2007  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2008  *	interface.
2009  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2010  *	for this interface.
2011  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2012  *	sizeof(void \*).
2013  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2014  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2015  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2016  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
2017  */
2018 struct ieee80211_vif {
2019 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
2020 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2021 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2022 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2023 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2024 	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2025 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2026 	bool p2p;
2027 
2028 	u8 cab_queue;
2029 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2030 
2031 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2032 
2033 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2034 	u32 driver_flags;
2035 	u32 offload_flags;
2036 
2037 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2038 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2039 #endif
2040 
2041 	bool probe_req_reg;
2042 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2043 
2044 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
2045 
2046 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2047 
2048 	/* must be last */
2049 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2050 };
2051 
2052 /**
2053  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2054  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2055  * Return: the usable link bitmap
2056  */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2057 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2058 {
2059 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2060 }
2061 
2062 /**
2063  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2064  * @vif: the vif
2065  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2066  */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2067 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2068 {
2069 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2070 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2071 }
2072 
2073 /**
2074  * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2075  * @vif: the vif
2076  * @link_id: the link ID to check
2077  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2078  *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2079  */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2080 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2081 					     unsigned int link_id)
2082 {
2083 	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2084 		return link_id == 0;
2085 	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2086 }
2087 
2088 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2089 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2090 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2091 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2092 		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2093 
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2094 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2095 {
2096 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2097 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2098 #endif
2099 	return false;
2100 }
2101 
2102 /**
2103  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2104  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2105  *
2106  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2107  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2108  *
2109  * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2110  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2111  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2112  */
2113 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2114 
2115 /**
2116  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2117  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2118  *
2119  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2120  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2121  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2122  *
2123  * Return: pointer to the wdev
2124  */
2125 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2126 
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2127 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2128 {
2129 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2130 }
2131 
2132 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2133 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2134 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2135 
2136 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2137 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2138 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2139 
2140 /**
2141  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2142  *
2143  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2144  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2145  *
2146  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2147  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2148  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2149  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2150  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2151  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2152  *	generation in software.
2153  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2154  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2155  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2156  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2157  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2158  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2159  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2160  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2161  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2162  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2163  *	MIC.
2164  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2165  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2166  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2167  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2168  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2169  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2170  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2171  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2172  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2173  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2174  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2175  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2176  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2177  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2178  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2179  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2180  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2181  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2182  *	for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2183  *	number generation only
2184  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2185  *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2186  */
2187 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2188 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2189 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2190 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2191 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2192 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2193 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2194 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2195 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2196 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2197 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2198 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2199 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2200 };
2201 
2202 /**
2203  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2204  *
2205  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2206  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2207  *
2208  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2209  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2210  *	encrypted in hardware.
2211  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2212  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2213  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2214  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2215  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2216  * @keylen: key material length
2217  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2218  * 	data block:
2219  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2220  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2221  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2222  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2223  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2224  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2225  */
2226 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2227 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2228 	u32 cipher;
2229 	u8 icv_len;
2230 	u8 iv_len;
2231 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2232 	s8 keyidx;
2233 	u16 flags;
2234 	s8 link_id;
2235 	u8 keylen;
2236 	u8 key[];
2237 };
2238 
2239 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2240 
2241 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2242 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2243 
2244 /**
2245  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2246  *
2247  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2248  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2249  *	reverse order than in packet)
2250  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2251  *	reverse order than in packet)
2252  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2253  *	reverse order than in packet)
2254  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2255  *	reverse order than in packet)
2256  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2257  */
2258 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2259 	union {
2260 		struct {
2261 			u32 iv32;
2262 			u16 iv16;
2263 		} tkip;
2264 		struct {
2265 			u8 pn[6];
2266 		} ccmp;
2267 		struct {
2268 			u8 pn[6];
2269 		} aes_cmac;
2270 		struct {
2271 			u8 pn[6];
2272 		} aes_gmac;
2273 		struct {
2274 			u8 pn[6];
2275 		} gcmp;
2276 		struct {
2277 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2278 			u8 seq_len;
2279 		} hw;
2280 	};
2281 };
2282 
2283 /**
2284  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2285  *
2286  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2287  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2288  *
2289  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2290  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2291  */
2292 enum set_key_cmd {
2293 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2294 };
2295 
2296 /**
2297  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2298  *
2299  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2300  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2301  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2302  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2303  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2304  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2305  */
2306 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2307 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2308 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2309 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2310 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2311 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2312 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2313 };
2314 
2315 /**
2316  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2317  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2318  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2319  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2320  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2321  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2322  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2323  *
2324  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2325  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2326  */
2327 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2328 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2329 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2330 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2331 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2332 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2333 };
2334 
2335 /**
2336  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2337  *
2338  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2339  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2340  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2341  */
2342 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2343 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2344 	struct {
2345 		s8 idx;
2346 		u8 count;
2347 		u8 count_cts;
2348 		u8 count_rts;
2349 		u16 flags;
2350 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2351 };
2352 
2353 /**
2354  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2355  *
2356  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2357  *
2358  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2359  *	to the STA.
2360  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2361  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2362  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2363  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2364  *	per peer TPC.
2365  */
2366 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2367 	s16 power;
2368 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2369 };
2370 
2371 /**
2372  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2373  *
2374  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2375  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2376  *
2377  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2378  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2379  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2380  *
2381  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2382  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2383  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2384  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2385  *
2386  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2387  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2388  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2389  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2390  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2391  */
2392 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2393 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2394 
2395 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2396 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2397 };
2398 
2399 /**
2400  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2401  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2402  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2403  *
2404  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2405  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2406  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2407  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2408  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2409  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2410  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2411  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2412  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2413  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2414  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2415  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2416  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2417  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2418  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2419  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2420  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2421  *	the station moves to associated state.
2422  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2423  *
2424  */
2425 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2426 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2427 
2428 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2429 	u8 link_id;
2430 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2431 
2432 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2433 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2434 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2435 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2436 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2437 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2438 
2439 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2440 
2441 	u8 rx_nss;
2442 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2443 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2444 };
2445 
2446 /**
2447  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2448  *
2449  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2450  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2451  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2452  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2453  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2454  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2455  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2456  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2457  *
2458  * @addr: MAC address
2459  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2460  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2461  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2462  *	Can be modified by driver.
2463  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2464  *	otherwise always false)
2465  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2466  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2467  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2468  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2469  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2470  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2471  * @rates: rate control selection table
2472  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2473  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2474  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2475  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2476  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2477  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2478  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2479  *	unlimited.
2480  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2481  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2482  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2483  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2484  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2485  *	is used for non-data frames
2486  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2487  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2488  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2489  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2490  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2491  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2492  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2493  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2494  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2495  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2496  *	by the AP.
2497  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2498  * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2499  */
2500 struct ieee80211_sta {
2501 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2502 	u16 aid;
2503 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2504 	bool wme;
2505 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2506 	u8 max_sp;
2507 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2508 	bool tdls;
2509 	bool tdls_initiator;
2510 	bool mfp;
2511 	bool mlo;
2512 	bool spp_amsdu;
2513 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2514 
2515 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2516 
2517 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2518 
2519 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2520 
2521 	u16 valid_links;
2522 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2523 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2524 
2525 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2526 
2527 	/* must be last */
2528 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2529 };
2530 
2531 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2532 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2533 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2534 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2535 {
2536 	return true;
2537 }
2538 #endif
2539 
2540 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2541 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2542 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2543 
2544 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2545 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2546 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2547 
2548 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2549 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2550 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2551 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2552 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2553 
2554 /**
2555  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2556  *
2557  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2558  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2559  *
2560  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2561  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2562  */
2563 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2564 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2565 };
2566 
2567 /**
2568  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2569  *
2570  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2571  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2572  */
2573 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2574 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2575 };
2576 
2577 /**
2578  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2579  *
2580  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2581  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2582  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2583  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2584  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2585  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2586  *
2587  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2588  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2589  */
2590 struct ieee80211_txq {
2591 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2592 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2593 	u8 tid;
2594 	u8 ac;
2595 
2596 	/* must be last */
2597 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2598 };
2599 
2600 /**
2601  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2602  *
2603  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2604  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2605  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2606  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2607  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2608  *
2609  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2610  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2611  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2612  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2613  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2614  *	algorithm.
2615  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2616  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2617  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2618  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2619  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2620  *	CCK frames.
2621  *
2622  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2623  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2624  *	the FCS at the end.
2625  *
2626  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2627  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2628  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2629  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2630  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2631  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2632  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2633  *
2634  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2635  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2636  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2637  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2638  *
2639  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2640  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2641  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2642  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2643  *
2644  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2645  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2646  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2647  *
2648  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2649  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2650  *
2651  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2652  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2653  *
2654  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2655  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2656  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2657  *
2658  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2659  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2660  *
2661  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2662  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2663  *
2664  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2665  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2666  *	the stack.
2667  *
2668  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2669  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2670  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2671  *
2672  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2673  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2674  *	dtim_period).
2675  *
2676  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2677  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2678  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2679  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2680  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2681  *	only in that case.
2682  *
2683  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2684  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2685  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2686  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2687  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2688  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2689  *
2690  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2691  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2692  *	software.
2693  *
2694  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2695  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2696  *	active interfaces.
2697  *
2698  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2699  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2700  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2701  *
2702  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2703  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2704  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2705  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2706  *	supported cipher suites.
2707  *
2708  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2709  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2710  *	for frames.
2711  *
2712  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2713  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2714  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2715  *	control for more details.
2716  *
2717  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2718  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2719  *
2720  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2721  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2722  *	is supported.
2723  *
2724  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2725  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2726  *
2727  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2728  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2729  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2730  *
2731  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2732  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2733  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2734  *	CSA frame.
2735  *
2736  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2737  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2738  *
2739  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2740  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2741  *
2742  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2743  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2744  *
2745  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2746  *	within A-MPDU.
2747  *
2748  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2749  *	for sent beacons.
2750  *
2751  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2752  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2753  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2754  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2755  *
2756  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2757  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2758  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2759  *	timeout.
2760  *
2761  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2762  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2763  *
2764  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2765  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2766  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2767  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2768  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2769  *
2770  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2771  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2772  *
2773  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2774  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2775  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2776  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2777  *
2778  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2779  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2780  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2781  *
2782  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2783  *	TDLS links.
2784  *
2785  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2786  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2787  *
2788  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2789  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2790  *
2791  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2792  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2793  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2794  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2795  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2796  *
2797  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2798  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2799  *	TXQs to start with.
2800  *
2801  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2802  *	length in tx status information
2803  *
2804  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2805  *
2806  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2807  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2808  *
2809  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2810  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2811  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2812  *
2813  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2814  *	offload
2815  *
2816  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2817  *	offload
2818  *
2819  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2820  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2821  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2822  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2823  *	the stack.
2824  *
2825  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2826  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2827  *
2828  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2829  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2830  *
2831  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2832  *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2833  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ: HW requires disabling puncturing in
2834  *	EHT in 5 GHz and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2835  *
2836  * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2837  *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2838  *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2839  *	link is switching.
2840  *
2841  * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2842  *	but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2843  *	HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2844  *	testing.
2845  *
2846  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2847  */
2848 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2849 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2850 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2851 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2852 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2853 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2854 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2855 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2856 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2857 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2858 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2859 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2860 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2861 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2862 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2863 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2864 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2865 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2866 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2867 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2868 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2869 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2870 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2871 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2872 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2873 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2874 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2875 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2876 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2877 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2878 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2879 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2880 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2881 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2882 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2883 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2884 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2885 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2886 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2887 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2888 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2889 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2890 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2891 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2892 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2893 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2894 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2895 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2896 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2897 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2898 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2899 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2900 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2901 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2902 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2903 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ,
2904 	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2905 	IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2906 
2907 	/* keep last, obviously */
2908 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2909 };
2910 
2911 /**
2912  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2913  *
2914  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2915  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2916  *
2917  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2918  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2919  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2920  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2921  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2922  *
2923  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2924  *
2925  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2926  *	along with this structure.
2927  *
2928  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2929  *
2930  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2931  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2932  *
2933  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2934  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2935  *
2936  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2937  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2938  *
2939  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2940  *	that HW supports
2941  *
2942  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2943  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2944  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2945  *
2946  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2947  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2948  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2949  *
2950  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2951  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2952  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2953  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2954  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2955  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2956  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2957  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2958  *
2959  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2960  *	can handle.
2961  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2962  *	the hw can report back.
2963  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2964  *
2965  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2966  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2967  *	aggregation.
2968  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2969  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2970  *	it shouldn't be set.
2971  *
2972  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2973  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2974  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2975  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2976  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2977  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2978  *
2979  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2980  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2981  *
2982  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2983  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2984  *
2985  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2986  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2987  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2988  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2989  *
2990  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2991  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2992  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2993  *
2994  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2995  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2996  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2997  *	device_timestamp.
2998  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2999  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3000  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3001  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3002  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3003  *
3004  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3005  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3006  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3007  *
3008  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3009  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3010  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3011  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3012  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3013  *	neither enabled.
3014  *
3015  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3016  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3017  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3018  *
3019  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3020  *	device.
3021  *
3022  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3023  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3024  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3025  *
3026  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3027  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3028  *
3029  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3030  *
3031  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3032  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3033  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3034  *
3035  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3036  */
3037 struct ieee80211_hw {
3038 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3039 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
3040 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3041 	void *priv;
3042 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3043 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3044 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3045 	int vif_data_size;
3046 	int sta_data_size;
3047 	int chanctx_data_size;
3048 	int txq_data_size;
3049 	u16 queues;
3050 	u16 max_listen_interval;
3051 	s8 max_signal;
3052 	u8 max_rates;
3053 	u8 max_report_rates;
3054 	u8 max_rate_tries;
3055 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3056 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3057 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
3058 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3059 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3060 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3061 	struct {
3062 		int units_pos;
3063 		s16 accuracy;
3064 	} radiotap_timestamp;
3065 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3066 	u8 uapsd_queues;
3067 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3068 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3069 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3070 	u8 weight_multiplier;
3071 	u32 max_mtu;
3072 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3073 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3074 
3075 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3076 };
3077 
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3078 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3079 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3080 {
3081 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3082 }
3083 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3084 
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3085 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3086 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3087 {
3088 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3089 }
3090 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3091 
3092 /**
3093  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3094  *
3095  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3096  * @req: cfg80211 request.
3097  */
3098 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3099 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3100 
3101 	/* Keep last */
3102 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3103 };
3104 
3105 /**
3106  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3107  *
3108  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3109  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3110  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3111  * @status: channel-switch response status
3112  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3113  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3114  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3115  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3116  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3117  */
3118 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3119 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3120 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3121 	u8 action_code;
3122 	u32 status;
3123 	u32 timestamp;
3124 	u16 switch_time;
3125 	u16 switch_timeout;
3126 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3127 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3128 };
3129 
3130 /**
3131  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3132  *
3133  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3134  *
3135  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3136  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3137  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3138  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3139  * is already used internally by mac80211.
3140  *
3141  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3142  */
3143 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3144 
3145 /**
3146  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3147  *
3148  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3149  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3150  */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3151 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3152 {
3153 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3154 }
3155 
3156 /**
3157  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3158  *
3159  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3160  * @addr: the address to set
3161  */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3162 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3163 {
3164 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3165 }
3166 
3167 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3168 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3169 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3170 {
3171 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3172 		return NULL;
3173 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3174 }
3175 
3176 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3177 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3178 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3179 {
3180 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3181 		return NULL;
3182 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3183 }
3184 
3185 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3186 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3187 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3188 {
3189 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3190 		return NULL;
3191 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3192 }
3193 
3194 /**
3195  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3196  * @hw: the hardware
3197  * @skb: the skb
3198  *
3199  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3200  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3201  */
3202 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3203 
3204 /**
3205  * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3206  * @hw: the hardware
3207  * @skbs: the skbs
3208  *
3209  * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3210  * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3211  * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3212  * relevant locks to use it.
3213  */
3214 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3215 			      struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3216 
3217 /**
3218  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3219  *
3220  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3221  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3222  *
3223  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3224  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3225  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3226  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3227  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3228  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3229  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3230  *
3231  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3232  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3233  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3234  *
3235  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3236  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3237  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3238  * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3239  *
3240  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3241  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3242  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3243  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3244  *
3245  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3246  *
3247  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3248  * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3249  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3250  * based on the receive flags.
3251  *
3252  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3253  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3254  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3255  * keys.
3256  *
3257  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3258  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3259  * handler.
3260  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3261  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3262  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3263  * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3264  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3265  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3266  *
3267  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3268  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3269  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3270  *
3271  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3272  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3273  * requirements:
3274  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3275       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3276    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3277       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3278    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3279       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3280       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3281    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3282    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3283  */
3284 
3285 /**
3286  * DOC: Powersave support
3287  *
3288  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3289  *
3290  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3291  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3292  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3293  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3294  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3295  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3296  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3297  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3298  *
3299  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3300  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3301  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3302  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3303  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3304  *
3305  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3306  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3307  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3308  *
3309  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3310  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3311  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3312  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3313  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3314  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3315  * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3316  *
3317  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3318  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3319  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3320  * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3321  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3322  * periods.
3323  *
3324  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3325  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3326  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3327  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3328  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3329  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3330  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3331  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3332  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3333  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3334  *
3335  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3336  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3337  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3338  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3339  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3340  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3341  *
3342  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3343  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3344  */
3345 
3346 /**
3347  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3348  *
3349  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3350  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3351  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3352  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3353  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3354  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3355  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3356  *
3357  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3358  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3359  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3360  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3361  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3362  *
3363  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3364  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3365  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3366  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3367  *
3368  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3369  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3370  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3371  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3372  *
3373  *  - a list of information element IDs
3374  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3375  *
3376  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3377  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3378  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3379  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3380  * vendor information elements.
3381  *
3382  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3383  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3384  *
3385  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3386  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3387  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3388  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3389  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3390  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3391  *
3392  *
3393  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3394  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3395  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3396  * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3397  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3398  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3399  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3400  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3401  *
3402  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3403  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3404  * signal strength threshold checking.
3405  */
3406 
3407 /**
3408  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3409  *
3410  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3411  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3412  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3413  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3414  *
3415  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3416  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3417  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3418  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3419  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3420  * hardware flags.
3421  *
3422  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3423  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3424  * turned off otherwise.
3425  *
3426  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3427  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3428  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3429  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3430  */
3431 
3432 /**
3433  * DOC: Frame filtering
3434  *
3435  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3436  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3437  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3438  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3439  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3440  *
3441  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3442  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3443  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3444  *
3445  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3446  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3447  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3448  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3449  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3450  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3451  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3452  *
3453  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3454  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3455  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3456  * or dropped.
3457  *
3458  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3459  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3460  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3461  * the flag, but not clear it.
3462  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3463  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3464  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3465  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3466  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3467  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3468  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3469  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3470  */
3471 
3472 /**
3473  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3474  *
3475  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3476  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3477  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3478  *
3479  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3480  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3481  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3482  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3483  * the driver code.
3484  *
3485  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3486  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3487  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3488  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3489  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3490  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3491  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3492  *
3493  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3494  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3495  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3496  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3497  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3498  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3499  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3500  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3501  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3502  * @sta_notify callback.
3503  *
3504  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3505  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3506  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3507  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3508  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3509  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3510  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3511  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3512  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3513  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3514  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3515  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3516  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3517  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3518  *
3519  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3520  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3521  *
3522  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3523  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3524  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3525  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3526  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3527  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3528  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3529  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3530  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3531  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3532  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3533  *
3534  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3535  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3536  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3537  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3538  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3539  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3540  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3541  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3542  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3543  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3544  * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3545  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3546  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3547  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3548  *
3549  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3550  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3551  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3552  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3553  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3554  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3555  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3556  *
3557  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3558  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3559  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3560  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3561  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3562  *
3563  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3564  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3565  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3566  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3567  */
3568 
3569 /**
3570  * DOC: HW queue control
3571  *
3572  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3573  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3574  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3575  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3576  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3577  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3578  *
3579  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3580  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3581  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3582  *
3583  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3584  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3585  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3586  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3587  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3588  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3589  * the hardware queue.
3590  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3591  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3592  *
3593  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3594  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3595  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3596  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3597  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3598  *
3599  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3600  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3601  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3602  * off-channel queue:         9
3603  *
3604  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3605  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3606  *
3607  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3608  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3609  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3610  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3611  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3612  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3613  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3614  *
3615  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3616  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3617  *
3618  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3619  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3620  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3621  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3622  */
3623 
3624 /**
3625  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3626  *
3627  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3628  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3629  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3630  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3631  *
3632  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3633  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3634  *	multicast address.
3635  *
3636  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3637  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3638  *
3639  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3640  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3641  *
3642  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3643  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3644  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3645  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3646  *	honour this flag if possible.
3647  *
3648  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3649  *	station
3650  *
3651  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3652  *
3653  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3654  *
3655  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3656  *
3657  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3658  */
3659 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3660 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3661 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3662 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3663 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3664 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3665 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3666 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3667 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3668 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3669 };
3670 
3671 /**
3672  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3673  *
3674  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3675  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3676  *
3677  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3678  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3679  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3680  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3681  *
3682  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3683  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3684  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3685  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3686  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3687  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3688  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3689  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3690  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3691  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3692  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3693  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3694  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3695  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3696  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3697  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3698  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3699  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3700  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3701  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3702  */
3703 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3704 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3705 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3706 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3707 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3708 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3709 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3710 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3711 };
3712 
3713 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3714 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3715 
3716 /**
3717  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3718  *
3719  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3720  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3721  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3722  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3723  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3724  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3725  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3726  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3727  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3728  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3729  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3730  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3731  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3732  */
3733 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3734 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3735 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3736 	u16 tid;
3737 	u16 ssn;
3738 	u16 buf_size;
3739 	bool amsdu;
3740 	u16 timeout;
3741 };
3742 
3743 /**
3744  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3745  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3746  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3747  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3748  */
3749 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3750 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3751 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3752 };
3753 
3754 /**
3755  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3756  *
3757  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3758  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3759  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3760  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3761  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3762  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3763  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3764  *	the peer.
3765  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3766  *	by the peer
3767  */
3768 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3769 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3770 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3771 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3772 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3773 };
3774 
3775 /**
3776  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3777  *
3778  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3779  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3780  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3781  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3782  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3783  *
3784  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3785  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3786  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3787  */
3788 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3789 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3790 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3791 };
3792 
3793 /**
3794  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3795  *
3796  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3797  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3798  *
3799  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3800  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3801  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3802  *	of wowlan configuration)
3803  */
3804 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3805 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3806 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3807 };
3808 
3809 /**
3810  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3811  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3812  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3813  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3814  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3815  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3816  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3817  * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3818  *	while just having been associated
3819  * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3820  *	0 for a non-MLO connection.
3821  */
3822 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3823 	u16 duration;
3824 	u16 subtype;
3825 	u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3826 	int link_id;
3827 };
3828 
3829 /**
3830  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3831  *
3832  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3833  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3834  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3835  *
3836  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3837  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3838  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3839  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3840  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3841  *	Must be atomic.
3842  *
3843  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3844  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3845  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3846  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3847  *	or zero.
3848  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3849  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3850  *	is added.
3851  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3852  *
3853  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3854  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3855  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3856  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3857  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3858  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3859  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3860  *
3861  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3862  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3863  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3864  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3865  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3866  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3867  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3868  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3869  *	must return 1 from this function.
3870  *
3871  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3872  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3873  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3874  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3875  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3876  *
3877  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3878  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3879  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3880  *	in suspend().
3881  *
3882  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3883  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3884  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3885  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3886  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3887  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3888  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3889  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3890  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3891  *
3892  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3893  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3894  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3895  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3896  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3897  *
3898  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3899  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3900  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3901  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3902  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3903  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3904  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3905  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3906  *
3907  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3908  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3909  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3910  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3911  *
3912  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3913  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3914  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3915  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3916  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3917  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3918  *	can sleep.
3919  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3920  *	are not implemented.
3921  *
3922  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3923  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3924  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3925  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3926  *	The callback can sleep.
3927  *
3928  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3929  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3930  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3931  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3932  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3933  *	non-MLO connections.
3934  *	The callback can sleep.
3935  *
3936  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3937  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3938  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3939  *
3940  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3941  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3942  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3943  *
3944  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3945  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3946  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3947  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3948  *	which flags are changed.
3949  *	This callback can sleep.
3950  *
3951  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3952  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3953  *
3954  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3955  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3956  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3957  *	is enabled.
3958  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3959  *	The callback can sleep.
3960  *
3961  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3962  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3963  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3964  *	The callback must be atomic.
3965  *
3966  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3967  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3968  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3969  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3970  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3971  *
3972  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3973  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3974  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3975  *
3976  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3977  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3978  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3979  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3980  *	that power save is disabled.
3981  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3982  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3983  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3984  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3985  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3986  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3987  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3988  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3989  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3990  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3991  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3992  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3993  *	The callback can sleep.
3994  *
3995  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3996  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3997  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3998  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3999  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4000  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4001  *	The callback can sleep.
4002  *
4003  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4004  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
4005  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4006  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4007  *
4008  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4009  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4010  *
4011  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4012  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4013  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4014  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4015  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4016  *
4017  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4018  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4019  *	this notification.
4020  *	The callback can sleep.
4021  *
4022  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4023  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
4024  *	The callback can sleep.
4025  *
4026  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4027  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4028  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4029  *	The callback must be atomic.
4030  *
4031  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4032  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4033  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4034  *	should be set as well.
4035  *	The callback can sleep.
4036  *
4037  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4038  *	The callback can sleep.
4039  *
4040  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4041  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4042  *
4043  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4044  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4045  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4046  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4047  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4048  *	This callback can sleep.
4049  *
4050  * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4051  *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4052  *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4053  *
4054  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4055  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4056  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4057  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4058  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4059  *
4060  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4061  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4062  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4063  *	callback can sleep.
4064  *
4065  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4066  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4067  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4068  *	callback can sleep.
4069  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4070  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4071  *
4072  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4073  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4074  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4075  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4076  *
4077  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4078  *	power for the station.
4079  *	This callback can sleep.
4080  *
4081  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4082  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4083  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4084  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4085  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4086  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4087  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4088  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4089  *	The callback can sleep.
4090  *
4091  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4092  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4093  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4094  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4095  *	in @sta_state.
4096  *	The callback can sleep.
4097  *
4098  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
4099  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4100  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4101  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4102  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4103  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4104  *	Must be atomic.
4105  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4106  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4107  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4108  *
4109  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4110  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4111  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4112  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4113  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4114  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4115  *	The callback can sleep.
4116  *
4117  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4118  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4119  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4120  *	The callback can sleep.
4121  *
4122  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4123  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4124  *	required function.
4125  *	The callback can sleep.
4126  *
4127  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4128  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4129  *	required function.
4130  *	The callback can sleep.
4131  *
4132  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4133  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4134  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4135  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4136  *	The callback can sleep.
4137  *
4138  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4139  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4140  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4141  *	TSF synchronization.
4142  *	The callback can sleep.
4143  *
4144  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4145  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4146  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4147  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4148  *	The callback can sleep.
4149  *
4150  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4151  *
4152  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4153  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4154  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4155  *	The callback can sleep.
4156  *
4157  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4158  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4159  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4160  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4161  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4162  *
4163  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4164  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4165  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4166  *
4167  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4168  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4169  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4170  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4171  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4172  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4173  *	The callback can sleep.
4174  *
4175  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4176  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4177  *	The callback can sleep.
4178  *
4179  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4180  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4181  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4182  *	completion of the channel switch.
4183  *
4184  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4185  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4186  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4187  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4188  *
4189  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4190  *
4191  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4192  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4193  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4194  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4195  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4196  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4197  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4198  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4199  *	must be accepted in this case.
4200  *	This callback may sleep.
4201  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4202  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4203  *
4204  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4205  *
4206  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4207  *
4208  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4209  *	queues before entering power save.
4210  *
4211  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4212  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4213  *	The callback can sleep.
4214  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4215  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4216  *	The callback must be atomic.
4217  *
4218  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4219  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4220  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4221  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4222  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4223  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4224  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4225  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4226  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4227  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4228  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4229  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4230  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4231  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4232  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4233  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4234  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4235  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4236  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4237  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4238  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4239  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4240  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4241  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4242  *	This callback must be atomic.
4243  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4244  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4245  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4246  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4247  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4248  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4249  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4250  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4251  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4252  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4253  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4254  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4255  *	This callback must be atomic.
4256  *
4257  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4258  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4259  *	expected to return a static value.
4260  *
4261  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4262  *
4263  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4264  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4265  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4266  *	expected to return a static value.
4267  *
4268  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4269  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4270  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4271  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4272  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4273  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4274  *	management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4275  *	to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4276  *	able to synchronize with the GO.
4277  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4278  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4279  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4280  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4281  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4282  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4283  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4284  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4285  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4286  *	Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4287  *	example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4288  *
4289  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4290  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4291  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4292  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4293  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4294  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4295  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4296  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4297  *
4298  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4299  *	This callback may sleep.
4300  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4301  *	This callback may sleep.
4302  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4303  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4304  *	channel context with different settings
4305  *	This callback may sleep.
4306  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4307  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4308  *	This callback may sleep.
4309  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4310  *	unbound from vif.
4311  *	This callback may sleep.
4312  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4313  *	another, as specified in the list of
4314  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4315  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4316  *	This callback may sleep.
4317  *
4318  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4319  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4320  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4321  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4322  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4323  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4324  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4325  *
4326  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4327  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4328  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4329  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4330  *	This callback may sleep.
4331  *
4332  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4333  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4334  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4335  *
4336  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4337  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4338  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4339  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4340  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4341  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4342  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4343  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4344  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4345  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4346  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4347  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4348  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4349  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4350  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4351  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4352  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4353  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4354  *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4355  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4356  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4357  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4358  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4359  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4360  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4361  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4362  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4363  *
4364  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4365  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4366  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4367  *
4368  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4369  *	and hardware limits.
4370  *
4371  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4372  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4373  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4374  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4375  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4376  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4377  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4378  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4379  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4380  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4381  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4382  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4383  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4384  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4385  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4386  *	the function call.
4387  *
4388  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4389  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4390  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4391  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4392  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4393  *
4394  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4395  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4396  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4397  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4398  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4399  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4400  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4401  *	changed parameters.
4402  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4403  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4404  *	this call.
4405  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4406  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4407  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4408  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4409  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4410  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4411  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4412  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4413  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4414  *
4415  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4416  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4417  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4418  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4419  *	This callback may sleep.
4420  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4421  *	This callback may sleep.
4422  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4423  *	4-address mode
4424  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4425  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4426  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4427  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4428  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4429  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4430  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4431  *	twt structure.
4432  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4433  *	from the peer.
4434  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4435  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4436  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4437  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4438  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4439  *	radar channel.
4440  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4441  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4442  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4443  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4444  * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4445  *	supported by the driver.
4446  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4447  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4448  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4449  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4450  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4451  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4452  *	Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4453  *	will be ignored in a removal only case.
4454  *	This callback can sleep.
4455  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4456  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4457  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4458  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4459  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4460  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4461  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4462  *	that.
4463  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4464  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4465  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4466  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4467  * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4468  *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4469  *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4470  *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4471  */
4472 struct ieee80211_ops {
4473 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4474 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4475 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4476 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4477 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4478 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4479 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4480 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4481 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4482 #endif
4483 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4484 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4485 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4486 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4487 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4488 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4489 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4490 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4491 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4492 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4494 				 u64 changed);
4495 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4496 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4497 				u64 changed);
4498 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4499 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4500 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4501 				  u64 changed);
4502 
4503 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4504 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4505 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4506 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4507 
4508 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4510 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4512 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4513 				 u64 multicast);
4514 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4515 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4516 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4517 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4518 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4519 		       bool set);
4520 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4521 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4522 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4523 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4524 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4525 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4526 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4527 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4528 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4530 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4531 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4532 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4533 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4535 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4537 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4540 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4541 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4542 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4543 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4545 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4546 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4548 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4549 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4550 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4551 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4552 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4553 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4554 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4555 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4556 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4557 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4558 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4559 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4560 	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4562 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4564 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4565 				 struct dentry *dir);
4566 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4568 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4569 				struct dentry *dir);
4570 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4571 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4572 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4573 				     struct dentry *dir);
4574 #endif
4575 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4576 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4577 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4579 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4580 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4582 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4583 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4584 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4586 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4587 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4588 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4589 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4590 			      u32 changed);
4591 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4593 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4594 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4597 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4598 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4599 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4601 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4602 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4603 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4604 			u64 tsf);
4605 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4606 			   s64 offset);
4607 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4608 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4609 
4610 	/**
4611 	 * @ampdu_action:
4612 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4613 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4614 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4615 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4616 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4617 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4618 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4619 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4620 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4621 	 *
4622 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4623 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4624 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4625 	 *
4626 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4627 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4628 	 *
4629 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4630 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4631 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4632 	 *
4633 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4634 	 *
4635 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4636 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4637 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4638 	 *
4639 	 * The callback can sleep.
4640 	 */
4641 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4644 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4645 		struct survey_info *survey);
4646 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4647 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4648 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4649 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4650 			    void *data, int len);
4651 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4652 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4653 			     void *data, int len);
4654 #endif
4655 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4656 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4657 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4658 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4659 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4660 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4661 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4662 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4663 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4664 
4665 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4666 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4667 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4668 				 int duration,
4669 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4670 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4671 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4672 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4673 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4674 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4675 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4676 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4677 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4678 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4680 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4681 
4682 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4683 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4684 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4685 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4686 				      bool more_data);
4687 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4688 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4689 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4690 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4691 					bool more_data);
4692 
4693 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4694 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4695 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4696 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4697 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4698 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4699 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4700 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4701 
4702 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4703 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4704 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4705 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4706 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4707 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4708 
4709 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4710 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4711 					     unsigned int link_id);
4712 
4713 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4715 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4716 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4717 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4718 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4719 			       u32 changed);
4720 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4721 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4723 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4724 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4726 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4727 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4728 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4729 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4730 				  int n_vifs,
4731 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4732 
4733 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4734 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4735 
4736 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4737 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4738 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4739 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4740 #endif
4741 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4742 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4743 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4744 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4745 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4746 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4747 
4748 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4749 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4750 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4751 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4752 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4753 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4754 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4755 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4756 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4757 
4758 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4759 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4760 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4761 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4762 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4763 			   int *dbm);
4764 
4765 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4766 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4767 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4768 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4769 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4770 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4771 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4772 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4773 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4774 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4775 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4776 
4777 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4778 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4779 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4780 
4781 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4782 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4783 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4784 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4785 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4786 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4787 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4788 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4789 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4790 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4791 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4792 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4793 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4794 			    u8 instance_id);
4795 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4796 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4797 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4798 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4799 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4800 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4801 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4802 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4803 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4804 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4805 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4806 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4807 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4808 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4809 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4810 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4811 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4812 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4814 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4815 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4816 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4818 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4819 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4820 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4821 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4822 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4823 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4824 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4825 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4826 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4827 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4828 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4829 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4830 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4831 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4832 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4833 	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4834 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4835 				   u16 active_links);
4836 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4837 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4838 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4839 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4840 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4841 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4842 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4843 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4844 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4845 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4846 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4847 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4848 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4849 			    struct net_device *dev,
4850 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4851 			    void *type_data);
4852 	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4853 	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4854 			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4855 
4856 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
4857 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
4858 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
4859 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
4860 };
4861 
4862 /**
4863  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4864  *
4865  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4866  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4867  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4868  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4869  * @priv_data_len.
4870  *
4871  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4872  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4873  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4874  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4875  *
4876  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4877  */
4878 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4879 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4880 					   const char *requested_name);
4881 
4882 /**
4883  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4884  *
4885  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4886  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4887  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4888  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4889  * @priv_data_len.
4890  *
4891  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4892  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4893  *
4894  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4895  */
4896 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4897 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4898 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4899 {
4900 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4901 }
4902 
4903 /**
4904  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4905  *
4906  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4907  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4908  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4909  *
4910  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4911  *
4912  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4913  */
4914 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4915 
4916 /**
4917  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4918  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4919  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4920  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4921  */
4922 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4923 	int throughput;
4924 	int blink_time;
4925 };
4926 
4927 /**
4928  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4929  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4930  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4931  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4932  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4933  */
4934 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4935 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4936 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4937 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4938 };
4939 
4940 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4941 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4942 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4943 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4944 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4945 const char *
4946 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4947 				   unsigned int flags,
4948 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4949 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4950 #endif
4951 /**
4952  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4953  *
4954  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4955  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4956  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4957  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4958  *
4959  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4960  *
4961  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4962  */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4963 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4964 {
4965 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4966 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4967 #else
4968 	return NULL;
4969 #endif
4970 }
4971 
4972 /**
4973  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4974  *
4975  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4976  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4977  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4978  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4979  *
4980  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4981  *
4982  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4983  */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4984 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4985 {
4986 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4987 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4988 #else
4989 	return NULL;
4990 #endif
4991 }
4992 
4993 /**
4994  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4995  *
4996  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4997  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4998  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4999  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5000  *
5001  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5002  *
5003  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5004  */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5005 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5006 {
5007 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5008 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5009 #else
5010 	return NULL;
5011 #endif
5012 }
5013 
5014 /**
5015  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5016  *
5017  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5018  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5019  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5020  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5021  *
5022  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5023  *
5024  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5025  */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5026 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5027 {
5028 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5029 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5030 #else
5031 	return NULL;
5032 #endif
5033 }
5034 
5035 /**
5036  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5037  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5038  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5039  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5040  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5041  *
5042  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5043  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5044  *
5045  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5046  */
5047 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5048 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5049 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5050 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5051 {
5052 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5053 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5054 						  blink_table_len);
5055 #else
5056 	return NULL;
5057 #endif
5058 }
5059 
5060 /**
5061  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5062  *
5063  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5064  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5065  *
5066  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5067  */
5068 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5069 
5070 /**
5071  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5072  *
5073  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5074  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5075  * before calling this function.
5076  *
5077  * @hw: the hardware to free
5078  */
5079 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5080 
5081 /**
5082  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5083  *
5084  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5085  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5086  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5087  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5088  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5089  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5090  *
5091  * @hw: the hardware to restart
5092  */
5093 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5094 
5095 /**
5096  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5097  *
5098  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5099  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5100  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5101  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5102  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5103  *
5104  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5105  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5106  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5107  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5108  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5109  *
5110  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5111  *
5112  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5113  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5114  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5115  * @list: the destination list
5116  */
5117 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5118 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5119 
5120 /**
5121  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5122  *
5123  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5124  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5125  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5126  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5127  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5128  *
5129  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5130  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5131  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5132  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5133  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5134  *
5135  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5136  *
5137  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5138  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5139  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5140  * @napi: the NAPI context
5141  */
5142 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5143 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5144 
5145 /**
5146  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5147  *
5148  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5149  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5150  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5151  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5152  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5153  *
5154  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5155  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5156  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5157  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5158  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5159  *
5160  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5161  *
5162  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5163  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5164  */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5165 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5166 {
5167 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5168 }
5169 
5170 /**
5171  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5172  *
5173  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5174  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5175  *
5176  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5177  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5178  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5179  *
5180  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5181  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5182  */
5183 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5184 
5185 /**
5186  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5187  *
5188  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5189  * (internally disables bottom halves).
5190  *
5191  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5192  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5193  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5194  *
5195  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5196  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5197  */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5198 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5199 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5200 {
5201 	local_bh_disable();
5202 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5203 	local_bh_enable();
5204 }
5205 
5206 /**
5207  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5208  *
5209  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5210  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5211  * entering/leaving PS mode.
5212  *
5213  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5214  *
5215  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5216  * each other.
5217  *
5218  * @sta: currently connected sta
5219  * @start: start or stop PS
5220  *
5221  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5222  */
5223 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5224 
5225 /**
5226  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5227  *                                  (in process context)
5228  *
5229  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5230  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5231  * applies.
5232  *
5233  * @sta: currently connected sta
5234  * @start: start or stop PS
5235  *
5236  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5237  */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5238 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5239 						  bool start)
5240 {
5241 	int ret;
5242 
5243 	local_bh_disable();
5244 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5245 	local_bh_enable();
5246 
5247 	return ret;
5248 }
5249 
5250 /**
5251  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5252  * @sta: currently connected station
5253  *
5254  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5255  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5256  * connected station was received.
5257  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5258  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5259  * be serialized.
5260  */
5261 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5262 
5263 /**
5264  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5265  * @sta: currently connected station
5266  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5267  *
5268  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5269  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5270  * from a connected station was received.
5271  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5272  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5273  * serialized.
5274  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5275  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5276  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5277  * checks.
5278  */
5279 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5280 
5281 /*
5282  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5283  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5284  */
5285 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5286 
5287 /**
5288  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5289  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5290  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5291  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5292  *
5293  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5294  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5295  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5296  *
5297  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5298  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5299  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5300  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5301  *
5302  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5303  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5304  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5305  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5306  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5307  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5308  *
5309  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5310  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5311  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5312  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5313  * use this API.
5314  */
5315 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5316 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5317 
5318 /**
5319  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5320  *
5321  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5322  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5323  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5324  *
5325  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5326  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5327  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5328  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5329  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5330  */
5331 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5332 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5333 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5334 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5335 			    int max_rates);
5336 
5337 /**
5338  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5339  *
5340  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5341  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5342  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5343  *
5344  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5345  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5346  * @info: tx status information
5347  */
5348 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5349 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5350 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5351 
5352 /**
5353  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5354  *
5355  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5356  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5357  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5358  *
5359  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5360  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5361  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5362  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5363  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5364  *
5365  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5366  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5367  */
5368 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5369 			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5370 
5371 /**
5372  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5373  *
5374  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5375  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5376  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5377  *
5378  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5379  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5380  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5381  *
5382  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5383  * @status: tx status information
5384  */
5385 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5386 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5387 
5388 /**
5389  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5390  *
5391  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5392  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5393  * specific skbs.
5394  *
5395  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5396  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5397  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5398  *
5399  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5400  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5401  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5402  * @info: tx status information
5403  */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5404 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5405 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5406 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5407 {
5408 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5409 		.sta = sta,
5410 		.info = info,
5411 	};
5412 
5413 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5414 }
5415 
5416 /**
5417  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5418  *
5419  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5420  *
5421  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5422  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5423  * for a single hardware.
5424  *
5425  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5426  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5427  */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5428 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5429 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5430 {
5431 	local_bh_disable();
5432 	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5433 	local_bh_enable();
5434 }
5435 
5436 /**
5437  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5438  *
5439  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5440  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5441  *
5442  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5443  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5444  *
5445  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5446  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5447  */
5448 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5449 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5450 
5451 /**
5452  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5453  *
5454  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5455  * connected STA.
5456  *
5457  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5458  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5459  */
5460 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5461 
5462 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5463 
5464 /**
5465  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5466  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5467  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5468  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5469  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5470  *	should be ignored.
5471  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5472  */
5473 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5474 	u16 tim_offset;
5475 	u16 tim_length;
5476 
5477 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5478 	u16 mbssid_off;
5479 };
5480 
5481 /**
5482  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5483  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5484  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5485  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5486  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5487  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5488  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5489  *
5490  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5491  * obtain the beacon template.
5492  *
5493  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5494  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5495  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5496  * applicable, the CSA count.
5497  *
5498  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5499  *
5500  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5501  */
5502 struct sk_buff *
5503 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5504 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5505 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5506 			      unsigned int link_id);
5507 
5508 /**
5509  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5510  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5511  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5512  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5513  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5514  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5515  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5516  *
5517  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5518  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5519  * requested index.
5520  *
5521  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5522  */
5523 struct sk_buff *
5524 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5525 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5526 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5527 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5528 
5529 /**
5530  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5531  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5532  *
5533  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5534  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5535  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5536  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5537  */
5538 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5539 	u8 cnt;
5540 	struct {
5541 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5542 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5543 	} bcn[];
5544 };
5545 
5546 /**
5547  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5548  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5549  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5550  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5551  *
5552  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5553  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5554  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5555  * one multiple BSSID element.
5556  *
5557  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5558  *
5559  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5560  *	%NULL on error.
5561  */
5562 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5563 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5564 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5565 				       unsigned int link_id);
5566 
5567 /**
5568  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5569  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5570  *
5571  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5572  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5573  */
5574 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5575 
5576 /**
5577  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5578  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5579  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5580  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5581  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5582  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5583  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5584  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5585  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5586  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5587  *
5588  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5589  * obtain the beacon frame.
5590  *
5591  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5592  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5593  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5594  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5595  *
5596  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5597  *
5598  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5599  */
5600 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5601 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5602 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5603 					 unsigned int link_id);
5604 
5605 /**
5606  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5607  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5608  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5609  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5610  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5611  *
5612  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5613  *
5614  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5615  */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5616 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5617 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5618 						   unsigned int link_id)
5619 {
5620 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5621 }
5622 
5623 /**
5624  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5625  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5626  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5627  *
5628  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5629  * This function is called implicitly when
5630  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5631  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5632  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5633  *
5634  * Return: new countdown value
5635  */
5636 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5637 				  unsigned int link_id);
5638 
5639 /**
5640  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5641  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5642  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5643  *
5644  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5645  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5646  *
5647  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5648  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5649  */
5650 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5651 
5652 /**
5653  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5654  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5655  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5656  *
5657  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5658  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5659  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5660  */
5661 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5662 
5663 /**
5664  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5665  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5666  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5667  *
5668  * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5669  */
5670 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5671 					 unsigned int link_id);
5672 
5673 /**
5674  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5675  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5676  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5677  *
5678  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5679  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5680  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5681  */
5682 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5683 
5684 /**
5685  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5686  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5687  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5688  *
5689  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5690  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5691  *
5692  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5693  *
5694  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5695  */
5696 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5697 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5698 
5699 /**
5700  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5701  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5702  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5703  *
5704  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5705  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5706  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5707  *
5708  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5709  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5710  *
5711  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5712  */
5713 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5714 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5715 
5716 /**
5717  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5718  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5719  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5720  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5721  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5722  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5723  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5724  *	if at all possible
5725  *
5726  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5727  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5728  * BSSID and address is used.
5729  *
5730  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5731  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5732  *
5733  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5734  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5735  *
5736  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5737  */
5738 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5739 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5740 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5741 
5742 /**
5743  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5744  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5745  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5746  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5747  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5748  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5749  *
5750  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5751  * hardware.
5752  *
5753  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5754  */
5755 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5756 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5757 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5758 				       size_t tailroom);
5759 
5760 /**
5761  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5762  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5763  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5764  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5765  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5766  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5767  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5768  *
5769  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5770  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5771  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5772  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5773  */
5774 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5775 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5776 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5777 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5778 
5779 /**
5780  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5781  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5782  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5783  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5784  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5785  *
5786  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5787  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5788  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5789  *
5790  * Return: The duration.
5791  */
5792 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5793 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5794 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5795 
5796 /**
5797  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5798  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5799  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5800  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5801  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5802  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5803  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5804  *
5805  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5806  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5807  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5808  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5809  */
5810 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5811 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5812 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5813 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5814 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5815 
5816 /**
5817  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5818  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5819  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5820  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5821  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5822  *
5823  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5824  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5825  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5826  *
5827  * Return: The duration.
5828  */
5829 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5830 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5831 				    size_t frame_len,
5832 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5833 
5834 /**
5835  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5836  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5837  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5838  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5839  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5840  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5841  *
5842  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5843  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5844  *
5845  * Return: The duration.
5846  */
5847 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5848 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5849 					enum nl80211_band band,
5850 					size_t frame_len,
5851 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5852 
5853 /**
5854  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5855  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5856  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5857  *
5858  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5859  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5860  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5861  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5862  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5863  *
5864  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5865  * frames are available.
5866  *
5867  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5868  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5869  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5870  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5871  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5872  * use common code for all beacons.
5873  */
5874 struct sk_buff *
5875 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5879  *
5880  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5881  *
5882  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5883  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5884  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5885  */
5886 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5887 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5888 
5889 /**
5890  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5891  *
5892  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5893  * from the given packet.
5894  *
5895  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5896  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5897  *	with this P1K
5898  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5899  */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5900 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5901 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5902 {
5903 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5904 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5905 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5906 
5907 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5908 }
5909 
5910 /**
5911  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5912  *
5913  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5914  * and transmitter address.
5915  *
5916  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5917  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5918  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5919  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5920  */
5921 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5922 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5923 
5924 /**
5925  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5926  *
5927  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5928  * in the packet.
5929  *
5930  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5931  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5932  *	encrypted with this key
5933  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5934  */
5935 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5936 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5937 
5938 /**
5939  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5940  *
5941  * @pos: start of crypto header
5942  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5943  * @pn: PN to add
5944  *
5945  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5946  * the packet payload)
5947  *
5948  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5949  * point to the crypto header)
5950  */
5951 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5952 
5953 /**
5954  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5955  *
5956  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5957  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5958  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5959  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5960  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5961  *
5962  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5963  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5964  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5965  *
5966  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5967  * can be done concurrently.
5968  */
5969 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5970 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5971 
5972 /**
5973  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5974  *
5975  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5976  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5977  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5978  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5979  * @seq: new sequence data
5980  *
5981  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5982  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5983  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5984  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5985  *
5986  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5987  * can be done concurrently.
5988  */
5989 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5990 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5991 
5992 /**
5993  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5994  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5995  *
5996  * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5997  *
5998  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5999  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
6000  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
6001  */
6002 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6003 
6004 /**
6005  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6006  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6007  * @keyconf: new key data
6008  * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6009  *
6010  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6011  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6012  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6013  *
6014  * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6015  * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6016  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6017  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6018  *
6019  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6020  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6021  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6022  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6023  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6024  * of the reconfiguration.
6025  *
6026  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6027  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6028  *
6029  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6030  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
6031  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
6032  * the key that's being replaced.
6033  */
6034 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6035 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6036 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6037 			int link_id);
6038 
6039 /**
6040  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6041  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6042  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6043  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6044  * @gfp: allocation flags
6045  */
6046 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6047 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6048 
6049 /**
6050  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6051  *
6052  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6053  * at the same time.
6054  *
6055  * @keyconf: the key in question
6056  */
6057 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6058 
6059 /**
6060  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6061  *
6062  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6063  * at the same time.
6064  *
6065  * @keyconf: the key in question
6066  */
6067 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6068 
6069 /**
6070  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6071  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6072  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6073  *
6074  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6075  */
6076 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6077 
6078 /**
6079  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6080  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6081  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6082  *
6083  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6084  */
6085 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6086 
6087 /**
6088  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6089  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6090  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6091  *
6092  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6093  *
6094  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6095  */
6096 
6097 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6098 
6099 /**
6100  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6101  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6102  *
6103  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6104  */
6105 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6106 
6107 /**
6108  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6109  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6110  *
6111  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6112  */
6113 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6114 
6115 /**
6116  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6117  *
6118  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6119  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6120  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6121  * any context, including hardirq context.
6122  *
6123  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6124  * @info: information about the completed scan
6125  */
6126 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6127 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6128 
6129 /**
6130  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6131  *
6132  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6133  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6134  *
6135  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6136  */
6137 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6138 
6139 /**
6140  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6141  *
6142  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6143  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6144  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6145  * while associating, for instance.
6146  *
6147  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6148  */
6149 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6150 
6151 /**
6152  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6153  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6154  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6155  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6156  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6157  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6158  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6159  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6160  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6161  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6162  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6163  *	for instance.
6164  */
6165 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6166 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6167 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6168 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6169 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6170 };
6171 
6172 /**
6173  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6174  *
6175  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6176  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6177  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6178  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6179  *
6180  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6181  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6182  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6183  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6184  */
6185 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6186 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6187 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6188 				  void *data);
6189 
6190 /**
6191  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6192  *
6193  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6194  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6195  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6196  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6197  * be used.
6198  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6199  *
6200  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6201  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6202  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6203  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6204  */
6205 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6206 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6207 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6208 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6209 				    void *data)
6210 {
6211 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6212 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6213 				     iterator, data);
6214 }
6215 
6216 /**
6217  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6218  *
6219  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6220  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6221  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6222  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6223  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6224  *
6225  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6226  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6227  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6228  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6229  */
6230 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6231 						u32 iter_flags,
6232 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6233 						    u8 *mac,
6234 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6235 						void *data);
6236 
6237 /**
6238  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6239  *
6240  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6241  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6242  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6243  *
6244  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6245  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6246  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6247  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6248  */
6249 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6250 					     u32 iter_flags,
6251 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6252 						u8 *mac,
6253 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6254 					     void *data);
6255 
6256 /**
6257  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6258  *
6259  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6260  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6261  * function for them.
6262  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6263  *
6264  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6265  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6266  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6267  */
6268 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6269 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6270 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6271 				       void *data);
6272 
6273 /**
6274  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6275  *
6276  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6277  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6278  * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6279  * mutex.
6280  *
6281  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6282  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6283  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6284  */
6285 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6286 				    void (*iterator)(void *data,
6287 						     struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6288 				    void *data);
6289 
6290 /**
6291  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6292  *
6293  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6294  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6295  *
6296  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6297  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6298  */
6299 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6300 
6301 /**
6302  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6303  *
6304  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6305  * workqueue.
6306  *
6307  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6308  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6309  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6310  */
6311 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6312 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6313 				  unsigned long delay);
6314 
6315 /**
6316  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6317  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6318  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6319  *
6320  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6321  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6322  * mac80211.
6323  *
6324  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6325  */
6326 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6327 					    u16 tid);
6328 
6329 /**
6330  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6331  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6332  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6333  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6334  *
6335  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6336  *
6337  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6338  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6339  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6340  */
6341 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6342 				  u16 timeout);
6343 
6344 /**
6345  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6346  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6347  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6348  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6349  *
6350  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6351  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6352  * from any context.
6353  */
6354 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6355 				      u16 tid);
6356 
6357 /**
6358  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6359  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6360  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6361  *
6362  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6363  *
6364  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6365  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6366  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6367  */
6368 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6369 
6370 /**
6371  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6372  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6373  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6374  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6375  *
6376  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6377  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6378  * can be called from any context.
6379  */
6380 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6381 				     u16 tid);
6382 
6383 /**
6384  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6385  *
6386  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6387  * @addr: station's address
6388  *
6389  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6390  *
6391  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6392  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6393  */
6394 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6395 					 const u8 *addr);
6396 
6397 /**
6398  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6399  *
6400  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6401  * @addr: remote station's address
6402  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6403  *
6404  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6405  *
6406  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6407  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6408  *
6409  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6410  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6411  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6412  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6413  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6414  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6415  *      is not reliable.
6416  *
6417  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6418  */
6419 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6420 					       const u8 *addr,
6421 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6422 
6423 /**
6424  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6425  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6426  * @addr: remote station's link address
6427  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6428  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6429  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6430  *
6431  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6432  *
6433  * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6434  */
6435 struct ieee80211_sta *
6436 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6437 				 const u8 *addr,
6438 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6439 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6440 
6441 /**
6442  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6443  * @hw: the hardware
6444  * @pubsta: the station
6445  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6446  *
6447  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6448  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6449  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6450  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6451  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6452  *
6453  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6454  * manner.
6455  *
6456  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6457  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6458  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6459  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6460  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6461  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6462  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6463  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6464  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6465  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6466  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6467  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6468  * woke up while blocked or not.
6469  */
6470 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6471 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6472 
6473 /**
6474  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6475  * @pubsta: the station
6476  *
6477  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6478  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6479  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6480  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6481  *
6482  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6483  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6484  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6485  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6486  *
6487  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6488  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6489  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6490  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6491  */
6492 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6493 
6494 /**
6495  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6496  * @pubsta: the station
6497  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6498  *
6499  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6500  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6501  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6502  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6503  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6504  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6505  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6506  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6507  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6508  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6509  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6510  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6511  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6512  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6513  */
6514 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6515 
6516 /**
6517  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6518  * @pubsta: the station
6519  *
6520  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6521  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6522  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6523  *
6524  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6525  * there is no need to call this function.
6526  */
6527 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6528 
6529 /**
6530  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6531  *
6532  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6533  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6534  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6535  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6536  *
6537  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6538  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6539  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6540  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6541  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6542  * attempts.
6543  *
6544  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6545  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6546  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6547  * them to 0.
6548  *
6549  * @pubsta: the station
6550  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6551  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6552  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6553  */
6554 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6555 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6556 
6557 /**
6558  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6559  *
6560  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6561  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6562  *
6563  * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6564  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6565  */
6566 bool
6567 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6568 
6569 /**
6570  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6571  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6572  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6573  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6574  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6575  *
6576  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6577  *
6578  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6579  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6580  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6581  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6582  *
6583  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6584  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6585  * set_key callback.
6586  */
6587 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6588 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6589 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6590 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6591 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6592 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6593 				      void *data),
6594 			 void *iter_data);
6595 
6596 /**
6597  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6598  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6599  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6600  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6601  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6602  *
6603  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6604  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6605  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6606  * in removal process will be skipped.
6607  *
6608  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6609  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6610  */
6611 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6612 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6613 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6614 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6615 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6616 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6617 					  void *data),
6618 			     void *iter_data);
6619 
6620 /**
6621  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6622  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6623  * @iter: iterator function
6624  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6625  *
6626  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6627  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6628  * places while calling into the driver.
6629  *
6630  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6631  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6632  * removed.
6633  *
6634  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6635  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6636  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6637  * or not.
6638  */
6639 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6640 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6641 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6642 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6643 		     void *data),
6644 	void *iter_data);
6645 
6646 /**
6647  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6648  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6649  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6650  *
6651  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6652  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6653  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6654  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6655  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6656  * %NULL.
6657  *
6658  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6659  */
6660 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6661 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6662 
6663 /**
6664  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6665  *
6666  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6667  *
6668  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6669  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6670  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6671  */
6672 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6673 
6674 /**
6675  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6676  *
6677  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6678  *
6679  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6680  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6681  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6682  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6683  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6684  *
6685  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6686  * without connection recovery attempts.
6687  */
6688 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6689 
6690 /**
6691  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6692  *
6693  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6694  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6695  *
6696  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6697  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6698  */
6699 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6700 
6701 /**
6702  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6703  *
6704  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6705  *
6706  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6707  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6708  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6709  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6710  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6711  *
6712  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6713  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6714  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6715  * disconnect normally later.
6716  *
6717  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6718  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6719  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6720  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6721  */
6722 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6723 
6724 /**
6725  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6726  * hardware restart
6727  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6728  *
6729  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6730  * hardware restart.
6731  */
6732 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6733 
6734 /**
6735  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6736  *	rssi threshold triggered
6737  *
6738  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6739  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6740  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6741  * @gfp: context flags
6742  *
6743  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6744  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6745  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6746  */
6747 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6748 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6749 			       s32 rssi_level,
6750 			       gfp_t gfp);
6751 
6752 /**
6753  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6754  *
6755  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6756  * @gfp: context flags
6757  */
6758 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6759 
6760 /**
6761  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6762  *
6763  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6764  * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6765  *	pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6766  */
6767 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6768 			      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6769 
6770 /**
6771  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6772  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6773  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6774  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6775  *	false.
6776  *
6777  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6778  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6779  */
6780 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6781 			     unsigned int link_id);
6782 
6783 /**
6784  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6785  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6786  *
6787  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6788  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6789  * a deauth frame in this case.
6790  */
6791 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6792 
6793 /**
6794  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6795  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6796  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6797  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6798  *
6799  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6800  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6801  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6802  */
6803 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6804 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6805 
6806 /**
6807  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6808  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6809  */
6810 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6811 
6812 /**
6813  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6814  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6815  */
6816 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6817 
6818 /**
6819  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6820  *
6821  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6822  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6823  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6824  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6825  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6826  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6827  *
6828  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6829  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6830  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6831  */
6832 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6833 				  const u8 *addr);
6834 
6835 /**
6836  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6837  * @pubsta: station struct
6838  * @tid: the session's TID
6839  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6840  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6841  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6842  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6843  *
6844  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6845  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6846  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6847  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6848  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6849  */
6850 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6851 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6852 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6853 
6854 /**
6855  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6856  *
6857  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6858  * buffer.
6859  *
6860  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6861  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6862  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6863  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6864  */
6865 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6866 
6867 /**
6868  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6869  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6870  * @addr: station mac address
6871  * @tid: the rx tid
6872  */
6873 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6874 				 unsigned int tid);
6875 
6876 /**
6877  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6878  *
6879  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6880  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6881  * reordering.
6882  *
6883  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6884  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6885  *
6886  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6887  * @addr: station mac address
6888  * @tid: the rx tid
6889  */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6890 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6891 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6892 {
6893 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6894 		return;
6895 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6896 }
6897 
6898 /**
6899  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6900  *
6901  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6902  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6903  * reordering.
6904  *
6905  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6906  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6907  *
6908  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6909  * @addr: station mac address
6910  * @tid: the rx tid
6911  */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6912 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6913 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6914 {
6915 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6916 		return;
6917 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6918 }
6919 
6920 /**
6921  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6922  *
6923  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6924  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6925  *
6926  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6927  *
6928  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6929  * @addr: station mac address
6930  * @tid: the rx tid
6931  */
6932 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6933 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6934 
6935 /* Rate control API */
6936 
6937 /**
6938  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6939  *
6940  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6941  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6942  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6943  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6944  *	to be filled in
6945  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6946  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6947  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6948  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6949  *	RTS threshold
6950  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6951  *	if the selected rate supports it
6952  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6953  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6954  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6955  */
6956 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6957 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6958 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6959 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6960 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6961 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6962 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6963 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6964 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6965 	bool bss;
6966 };
6967 
6968 /**
6969  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6970  */
6971 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6972 	/**
6973 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6974 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6975 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6976 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6977 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6978 	 */
6979 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6980 	/**
6981 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6982 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6983 	 */
6984 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6985 };
6986 
6987 struct rate_control_ops {
6988 	unsigned long capa;
6989 	const char *name;
6990 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6991 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6992 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6993 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6994 
6995 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6996 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6997 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6998 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6999 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7000 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7001 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7002 			    u32 changed);
7003 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7004 			 void *priv_sta);
7005 
7006 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7007 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7008 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7009 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7010 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7011 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
7012 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7013 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7014 
7015 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7016 				struct dentry *dir);
7017 
7018 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7019 
7020 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
7021 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
7022 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
7023 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
7024 };
7025 
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7026 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7027 				 enum nl80211_band band,
7028 				 int index)
7029 {
7030 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7031 }
7032 
7033 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7034 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7035 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7036 {
7037 	int i;
7038 
7039 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7040 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7041 			return i;
7042 
7043 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7044 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7045 
7046 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7047 	return 0;
7048 }
7049 
7050 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7051 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7052 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7053 {
7054 	unsigned int i;
7055 
7056 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7057 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7058 			return true;
7059 	return false;
7060 }
7061 
7062 /**
7063  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7064  *
7065  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7066  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7067  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7068  * the most recent rate control module decision.
7069  *
7070  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7071  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7072  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7073  *
7074  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7075  */
7076 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7077 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7078 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7079 
7080 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7081 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7082 
7083 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7084 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7085 {
7086 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7087 }
7088 
7089 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7090 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7091 {
7092 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7093 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7094 }
7095 
7096 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7097 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7098 {
7099 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7100 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7101 }
7102 
7103 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7104 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7105 {
7106 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7107 }
7108 
7109 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7110 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7111 {
7112 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7113 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7114 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7115 }
7116 
7117 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7118 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7119 {
7120 	if (p2p) {
7121 		switch (type) {
7122 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7123 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7124 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7125 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7126 		default:
7127 			break;
7128 		}
7129 	}
7130 	return type;
7131 }
7132 
7133 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7134 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7135 {
7136 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7137 }
7138 
7139 /**
7140  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7141  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7142  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7143  *
7144  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7145  */
7146 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7147 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7148 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7149 {
7150 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7151 }
7152 
7153 /**
7154  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7155  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7156  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7157  *
7158  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7159  */
7160 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7161 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7162 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7163 {
7164 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7165 }
7166 
7167 /**
7168  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7169  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7170  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7171  *
7172  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7173  */
7174 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7175 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7176 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7177 {
7178 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7179 }
7180 
7181 /**
7182  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7183  *
7184  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7185  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7186  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7187  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7188  *
7189  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7190  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7191  * matching GroupId management frame.
7192  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7193  */
7194 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7195 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7196 
7197 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7198 				   int rssi_min_thold,
7199 				   int rssi_max_thold);
7200 
7201 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7202 
7203 /**
7204  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7205  *
7206  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7207  *
7208  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7209  *
7210  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7211  * applicable.
7212  */
7213 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7214 
7215 /**
7216  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7217  * @vif: virtual interface
7218  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7219  * @gfp: allocation flags
7220  *
7221  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7222  */
7223 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7224 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7225 				    gfp_t gfp);
7226 
7227 /**
7228  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7229  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7230  * @vif: virtual interface
7231  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7232  * @band: the band to transmit on
7233  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7234  *
7235  * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7236  *
7237  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7238  */
7239 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7240 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7241 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7242 
7243 /**
7244  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7245  *				 of injected frames.
7246  *
7247  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7248  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7249  * of the skb before calling this function.
7250  *
7251  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7252  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7253  *
7254  * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7255  */
7256 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7257 				 struct net_device *dev);
7258 
7259 /**
7260  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7261  *
7262  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7263  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7264  *
7265  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7266  *
7267  * private:
7268  *
7269  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7270  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7271  */
7272 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7273 	u32 next_tsf;
7274 	bool has_next_tsf;
7275 
7276 	u8 absent;
7277 
7278 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7279 	struct {
7280 		u32 start;
7281 		u32 duration;
7282 		u32 interval;
7283 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7284 };
7285 
7286 /**
7287  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7288  *
7289  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7290  * @data: NoA tracking data
7291  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7292  *
7293  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7294  */
7295 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7296 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7297 
7298 /**
7299  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7300  *
7301  * @data: NoA tracking data
7302  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7303  */
7304 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7305 
7306 /**
7307  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7308  * @vif: virtual interface
7309  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7310  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7311  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7312  * @gfp: allocation flags
7313  *
7314  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7315  */
7316 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7317 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7318 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7319 
7320 /**
7321  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7322  *
7323  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7324  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7325  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7326  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7327  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7328  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7329  *
7330  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7331  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7332  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7333  *
7334  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7335  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7336  *
7337  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7338  */
7339 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7340 
7341 /**
7342  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7343  *
7344  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7345  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7346  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7347  *
7348  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7349  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7350  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7351  *
7352  * @sta: the station
7353  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7354  */
7355 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7356 
7357 /**
7358  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7359  *
7360  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7361  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7362  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7363  *
7364  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7365  *
7366  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7367  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7368  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7369  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7370  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7371  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7372  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7373  *
7374  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7375  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7376  */
7377 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7378 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7379 
7380 /**
7381  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7382  * (in process context)
7383  *
7384  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7385  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7386  *
7387  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7388  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7389  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7390  *
7391  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7392  */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7393 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7394 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7395 {
7396 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7397 
7398 	local_bh_disable();
7399 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7400 	local_bh_enable();
7401 
7402 	return skb;
7403 }
7404 
7405 /**
7406  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7407  *
7408  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7409  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7410  *
7411  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7412  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7413  */
7414 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7415 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7416 
7417 /**
7418  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7419  *
7420  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7421  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7422  *
7423  * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7424  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7425  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7426  */
7427 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7428 
7429 /**
7430  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7431  *
7432  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7433  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7434  *
7435  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7436  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7437  */
7438 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7439 
7440 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7441 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7442 {
7443 }
7444 
7445 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7446 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7447 
7448 /**
7449  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7450  *
7451  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7452  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7453  *
7454  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7455  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7456  *
7457  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7458  * this TXQ internally.
7459  */
7460 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7461 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7462 {
7463 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7464 }
7465 
7466 /**
7467  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7468  *
7469  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7470  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7471  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7472  *
7473  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7474  * internally.
7475  */
7476 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7477 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7478 		     bool force)
7479 {
7480 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7481 }
7482 
7483 /**
7484  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7485  *
7486  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7487  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7488  * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7489  * next_txq().
7490  *
7491  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7492  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7493  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7494  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7495  * again.
7496  *
7497  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7498  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7499  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7500  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7501  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7502  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7503  *
7504  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7505  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7506  *
7507  * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7508  */
7509 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7510 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7511 
7512 /**
7513  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7514  *
7515  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7516  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7517  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7518  *
7519  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7520  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7521  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7522  */
7523 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7524 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7525 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7526 
7527 /**
7528  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7529  *
7530  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7531  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7532  *
7533  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7534  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7535  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7536  * @gfp: allocation flags
7537  */
7538 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7539 				   u8 inst_id,
7540 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7541 				   gfp_t gfp);
7542 
7543 /**
7544  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7545  *
7546  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7547  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7548  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7549  *
7550  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7551  * @match: match event information
7552  * @gfp: allocation flags
7553  */
7554 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7555 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7556 			      gfp_t gfp);
7557 
7558 /**
7559  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7560  *
7561  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7562  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7563  *
7564  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7565  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7566  *          information.
7567  * @len: frame length in bytes
7568  *
7569  * Return: the airtime estimate
7570  */
7571 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7572 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7573 			      int len);
7574 
7575 /**
7576  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7577  *
7578  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7579  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7580  *
7581  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7582  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7583  * @len: frame length in bytes
7584  *
7585  * Return: the airtime estimate
7586  */
7587 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7588 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7589 			      int len);
7590 /**
7591  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7592  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7593  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7594  *
7595  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7596  *
7597  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7598  */
7599 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7600 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7601 
7602 /**
7603  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7604  *	probe response template.
7605  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7606  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7607  *
7608  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7609  *
7610  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7611  */
7612 struct sk_buff *
7613 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7614 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7615 
7616 /**
7617  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7618  * collision.
7619  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7620  *
7621  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7622  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7623  *	aware of.
7624  */
7625 void
7626 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7627 				      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7628 
7629 /**
7630  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7631  *
7632  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7633  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7634  *
7635  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7636  *
7637  * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7638  */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7639 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7640 {
7641 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7642 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7643 
7644 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7645 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7646 }
7647 
7648 /**
7649  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7650  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7651  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7652  *
7653  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7654  *	back into the driver.
7655  *
7656  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7657  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7658  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7659  *
7660  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7661  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7662  * a sequence of calls like
7663  *
7664  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7665  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7666  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7667  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7668  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7669  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7670  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7671  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7672  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7673  *
7674  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7675  */
7676 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7677 
7678 /**
7679  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7680  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7681  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7682  *
7683  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7684  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7685  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7686  * completed after it returns.
7687  */
7688 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7689 				      u16 active_links);
7690 
7691 /**
7692  * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7693  * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7694  *
7695  * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7696  * TTLM request.
7697  */
7698 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7699 
7700 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7701 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7702 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7703 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7704 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7705 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7706 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7707 				      u32 changed);
7708 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7709 					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7710 					 int n_vifs,
7711 					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7712 
7713 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7714